blob: c699623882f867896f9464d1c3b8d7f995934ecd [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000032#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
33#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000035#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000037#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000038using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000039using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000040
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000041
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000042/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
43/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
44///
45/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
46/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
47/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
48/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
49/// function is being used.
50///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000051/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
52/// decls.
53///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000054/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
55/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000056///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000059 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000060 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000061 }
62
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 // See if the decl is unavailable
64 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek1ddd6d22010-07-21 20:43:11 +000065 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000066 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
67 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000068
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000069 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000070 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000071 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
72 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
73 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
74 return true;
75 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000076 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000077
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000078 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000079}
80
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000081/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000082/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000083/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
84///
85void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000086 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000087 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000088 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000089 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000090
91 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
92 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000093 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
94 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000095
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000096 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
97 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000098 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000099 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
100 int isMethod = 0;
101 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
102 // skip over named parameters.
103 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
104 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
105 if (nullPos)
106 --nullPos;
107 else
108 ++i;
109 }
110 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
111 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000112 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000113 // skip over named parameters.
114 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
115 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
116 if (nullPos)
117 --nullPos;
118 else
119 ++i;
120 }
121 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000122 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000123 // block or function pointer call.
124 QualType Ty = V->getType();
125 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000126 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000127 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
128 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000129 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
130 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
131 unsigned k;
132 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
133 if (nullPos)
134 --nullPos;
135 else
136 ++i;
137 }
138 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
139 }
140 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
141 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000142 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000143 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000144 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000145 return;
146
147 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000148 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000149 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000150 return;
151 }
152 int sentinel = i;
153 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
154 --sentinelPos;
155 ++i;
156 }
157 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
158 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000159 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000160 return;
161 }
162 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
163 ++i;
164 ++sentinel;
165 }
166 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000167 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
168 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
169 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000170 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000171 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
172 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
173 return;
174
175 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
176 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
177
178 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
179 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000180}
181
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000182SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
183 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
184 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
185}
186
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000187//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
188// Standard Promotions and Conversions
189//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
190
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000191/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
192void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
193 QualType Ty = E->getType();
194 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
195
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000196 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000197 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000198 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000199 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
200 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
201 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
202 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
203 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
204 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
205 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000206 //
207 // C++ 4.2p1:
208 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
209 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
210 //
211 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
212 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000213 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000214 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000215 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000216}
217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
219 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000220
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000221 QualType Ty = E->getType();
222 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
223 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
224 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
225 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
226 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
227 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
228 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
229 // rvalue is T
230 //
231 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000232 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
233 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000234 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000235 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000236 }
237}
238
239
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000240/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000241/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000242/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
243/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
244/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
245Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
246 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
247 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000248
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000249 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
250 //
251 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
252 // unsigned int may be used:
253 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
254 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
255 // and unsigned int.
256 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
257 //
258 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
259 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
260 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
261 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
263 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000264 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000265 return Expr;
266 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000268 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000269 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000270 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000271 }
272
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000273 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000274 return Expr;
275}
276
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000277/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000279/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
280void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
281 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
282 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000283
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000284 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000285 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
286 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000287 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000288
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000289 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
290}
291
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000292/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
293/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
294/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
295/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000296bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
297 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000298 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000299
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000300 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
301 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
302 // etc.
303 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
304 return false;
305
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000306 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000307 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
308 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
309 << Expr->getType() << CT))
310 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000311
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000312 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000313 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000314 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
315 << Expr->getType() << CT))
316 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000317
318 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000319}
320
321
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
323/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000324/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000325/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
326/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
327/// GCC.
328QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
329 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000330 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000331 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000332
333 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000334
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000335 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000336 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 QualType lhs =
338 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000339 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000340 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000341
342 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
343 if (lhs == rhs)
344 return lhs;
345
346 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
347 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
348 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
349 return lhs;
350
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000351 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000355 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000356 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
357 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
358
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000359 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000360 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000361 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
362 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363 return destType;
364}
365
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000366//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
367// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
368//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
369
370
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000371/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000372/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
373/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
374/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
375/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000376///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000377ExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000378Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000379 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
380
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000381 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000382 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000383 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000384
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000385 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000386 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
387 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000389 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000390 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000391 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392
393 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000394 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000395 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000396
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000397 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
398 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
399 // strings.
400 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000401 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000402 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000403
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000404 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000405 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000406 Literal.GetStringLength(),
407 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
408 &StringTokLocs[0],
409 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000410}
411
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000412/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
413/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
414/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
415/// for values inside the block or for globals).
416///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000417/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000418/// up-to-date.
419///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000420static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000421 ValueDecl *VD) {
422 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
423 // we wanted to.
424 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
425 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000426
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000427 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
428 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
429 return false;
430
431 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
432 // snapshot it.
433 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
434 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
436 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000437
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000438 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
439 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
440
441 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
442 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
443 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
444 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
446 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000448 if (!NextBlock)
449 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000450
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000451 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
452 // having a reference outside it.
453 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
454 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000455
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000456 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
457 // a snapshot as well.
458 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
459 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000462}
463
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000464
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000465ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000466Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000467 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000468 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
469 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
470}
471
472/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000473ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000474Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
475 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
476 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000477 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000478 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000479 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000480 << D->getDeclName();
481 return ExprError();
482 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000485 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
486 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
487 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000488 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000489 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000490 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
491 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000492 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
493 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000494 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000495 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000496 << D->getIdentifier();
497 return ExprError();
498 }
499 }
500 }
501 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000502
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000503 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000504
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000505 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
506 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
507 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000508 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000509}
510
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000511/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
512/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
513/// actual member.
514///
515/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
516/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
517/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
518/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
519/// we found.
520///
521/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
522/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
523/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
524VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
525 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
527 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
528 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
529
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000530 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000531 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
532 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
533 do {
534 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000535 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000536 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000537 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000538 else {
539 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
540 break;
541 }
542 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000544 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000545
546 return BaseObject;
547}
548
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000549ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000550Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
551 FieldDecl *Field,
552 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
553 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
554 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000555 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000556 AnonFields);
557
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000558 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
559 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
560 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
561 // found via name lookup.
562 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000563 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000564 if (BaseObject) {
565 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
566 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000567 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000568 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000569 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
573 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
574 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
575 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
576 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000577 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
579 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
580 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000581 BaseQuals
582 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000583 } else {
584 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
585 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
586 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000587 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
588 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000589 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000590 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000591 = Context.getTagDeclType(
592 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
593 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000594 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
596 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
597 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000598 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000599 MD->getThisType(Context),
600 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000601 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
602 }
603 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000604 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
605 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000606 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 }
609
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000610 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000611 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
612 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 }
614
615 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
616 // anonymous struct/union.
617 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000618 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
620 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
621 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
622 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000623 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
624 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
625
626 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
627 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
628 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
629 ResultQuals.removeConst();
630
631 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
632 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
633
634 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
635 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
636
637 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
638 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
639 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
640
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000641 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000642 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000643 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000644 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
645 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000646 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000647 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000648 }
649
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000650 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000651}
652
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000653/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000654/// possibly a list of template arguments.
655///
656/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
657/// DecomposeTemplateName.
658///
659/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
660/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
661/// some way.
662static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
663 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
664 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000665 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000666 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
667 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
668 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
669 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
670
671 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
672 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
673 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
674 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
675 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
676
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000677 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000678 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
679 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000680 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
681 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000682 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683 TemplateArgs = 0;
684 }
685}
686
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000687/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
688/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
689/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000690static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000691 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
692 return false;
693
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000694 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
695 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
696 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
697 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
698 if (!BaseRT) return false;
699
700 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000701 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000702 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
703 return false;
704 }
705
706 return true;
707}
708
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000709/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
710/// the prospective base classes.
711static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
712 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
713 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000714 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000715 return false;
716
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000717 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000718 if (!RD) return false;
719 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
720
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000721 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
722 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
723 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
724 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
725 if (!BaseRT) return false;
726
727 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000728 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
729 return false;
730 }
731
732 return true;
733}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000734
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000735enum IMAKind {
736 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
737 IMA_Static,
738
739 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
740 IMA_Mixed,
741
742 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
743 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
744 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
745
746 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
747 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
748 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
749
750 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
751 IMA_Instance,
752
753 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
754 IMA_Unresolved,
755
756 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
757 /// context is not an instance method.
758 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
759
760 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
761 /// non-class context.
762 IMA_AnonymousMember,
763
764 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
765 /// context is not an instance method.
766 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
767
768 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
769 /// class.
770 IMA_Error_Unrelated
771};
772
773/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
774/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
775/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
776/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
777/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
778/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
779static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
780 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000781 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000782
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000783 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000784 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000785 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
786 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000787
788 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
789 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
790
791 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
792 bool hasNonInstance = false;
793 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
794 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000795 NamedDecl *D = *I;
796 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000797 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
798
799 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
800 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
801 // that's a special case.
802 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
803 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
804 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
805 }
806 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
807 }
808 else
809 hasNonInstance = true;
810 }
811
812 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
813 // member reference.
814 if (Classes.empty())
815 return IMA_Static;
816
817 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
818 // an implicit member reference.
819 if (isStaticContext)
820 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
821
822 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
823 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
824 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
825 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000826 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 Classes))
828 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
829
830 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
831}
832
833/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
834static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
835 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
836 const LookupResult &R) {
837 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
838 SourceRange Range(Loc);
839 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
840
841 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
842 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
843 if (MD->isStatic()) {
844 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
845 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
846 << Range << R.getLookupName();
847 return;
848 }
849 }
850
851 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
852 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
853 return;
854 }
855
856 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000857}
858
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000859/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
860///
861/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000862bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
863 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000864 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
865
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000866 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000867 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000868 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
869 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000870 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000871 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000872 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
873 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000875 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
876 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
877 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
878 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000879 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000880 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
882 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
883
884 if (!R.empty()) {
885 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
886 R.suppressDiagnostics();
887
888 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
889 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
890 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
891 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
892
893 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
894 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
895 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000896 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000897 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
898 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000899 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000900 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000901 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000902 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
903 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
904 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
905 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
906 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
907 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
908 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
909 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
910 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
911 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
912 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
913 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
914 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
915 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000916 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000917 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
918 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
919 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000920 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000921 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000922 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000923 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000924
925 // Do we really want to note all of these?
926 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
927 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
928
929 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
930 return false;
931 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000932
933 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000934 }
935 }
936
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000937 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000938 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000939 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000940 if (!R.empty()) {
941 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
942 if (SS.isEmpty())
943 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
944 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
945 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
946 else
947 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
948 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
949 << SS.getRange()
950 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
951 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
952 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
953 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
954 << ND->getDeclName();
955
956 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
957 return false;
958 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000959
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000960 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
961 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
962 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
963 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
964 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
965 // to recover well anyway.
966 if (SS.isEmpty())
967 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
968 else
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
970 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
971 << SS.getRange();
972
973 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
974 return true;
975 }
976 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000977 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000978 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000979 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000980 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000981 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000982 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
984 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000985 return true;
986 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000987 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000988 }
989
990 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
991 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
992 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
994 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
995 << SS.getRange();
996 return true;
997 }
998
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000999 // Give up, we can't recover.
1000 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1001 return true;
1002}
1003
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001004static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001005 IdentifierInfo *II,
1006 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001007 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1008 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1009 if (!IDecl)
1010 return 0;
1011 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1012 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1013 return 0;
1014 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1015 if (!property)
1016 return 0;
1017 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1018 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1019 return 0;
1020 return property;
1021}
1022
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001023static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001024 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001025 IdentifierInfo *II,
1026 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1027 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001028 bool LookForIvars;
1029 if (Lookup.empty())
1030 LookForIvars = true;
1031 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1032 LookForIvars = false;
1033 else
1034 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1035 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1036 if (!LookForIvars)
1037 return 0;
1038
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001039 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1040 if (!IDecl)
1041 return 0;
1042 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001043 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1044 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001045 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1046 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1047 if (!property)
1048 return 0;
1049 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1050 DynamicImplSeen =
1051 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1052 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001053 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1054 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001055 NameLoc,
1056 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1057 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1058 (Expr *)0, true);
1059 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1060 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1061 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1062 return Ivar;
1063 }
1064 return 0;
1065}
1066
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001067ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001068 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1069 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1070 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1071 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1073 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1074
1075 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001076 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001077
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001078 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001079
1080 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001081 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001083 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001084
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001085 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001086 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001087 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001088
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1090 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001091 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1092 // (note: handled after lookup)
1093 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1094 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1095 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001096 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1097 // names a dependent type.
1098 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1099 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001100 bool DependentID = false;
1101 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1102 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1103 DependentID = true;
1104 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1105 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1106 if (DC) {
1107 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1108 return ExprError();
1109 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1110 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1111 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1112 } else {
1113 DependentID = true;
1114 }
1115 }
1116
1117 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001118 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001119 TemplateArgs);
1120 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001121 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001122 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001123 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001124 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001125 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1126 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1127 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1128 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1129 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001130 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1131 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1132 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001133 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001134 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001135 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001136
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1138 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001139 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001140 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 if (E.isInvalid())
1142 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001143
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1145 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001146 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1147 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001148 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001149 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1150 isAddressOfOperand);
1151 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001152 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1153 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001154 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001155 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001156
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001157 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1158 return ExprError();
1159
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001160 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1161 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001162 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001163
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001164 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001165 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1167 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1168 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1169 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1170 }
1171
1172 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1173 // call, diagnose the problem.
1174 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001175 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001176 return ExprError();
1177
1178 assert(!R.empty() &&
1179 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001180
1181 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1182 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001183 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001184 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1185 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001186 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001187 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1188 return move(E);
1189 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001190 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001191 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001192
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001193 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1194 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1195
1196 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001197 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001198 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1199 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001200 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1201 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1202 if (Property) {
1203 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1204 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001205 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001206 }
1207 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001208 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001209 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1210 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1211 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1212 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1213 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1214 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001216 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001217
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001218 QualType T = Func->getType();
1219 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001220 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001221 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1222 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001223 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001224 }
1225 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001226
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001227 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001228 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1229 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1230 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1231 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1232 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1233 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1234 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1235 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001236 //
1237 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1238 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1239 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1240 // non-static member function:
1241 //
1242 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1243 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1244 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1245 // member function call.
1246 //
1247 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1248 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1249 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1250 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001251 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001252 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1253 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1254 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1255 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1256 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1257 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1258 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1259 else
1260 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1261
1262 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001263 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001264 }
1265
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001266 if (TemplateArgs)
1267 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001268
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001269 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1270}
1271
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001272/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001273ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001274Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1275 LookupResult &R,
1276 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1277 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1278 case IMA_Instance:
1279 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1280
1281 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1282 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1283 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1284 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1285
1286 case IMA_Mixed:
1287 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1288 case IMA_Unresolved:
1289 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1290
1291 case IMA_Static:
1292 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1293 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1294 if (TemplateArgs)
1295 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1296 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1297
1298 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1299 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1300 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1301 return ExprError();
1302 }
1303
1304 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1305 return ExprError();
1306}
1307
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001308/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1309/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1310/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1311/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001312ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001313Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001314 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001315 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001316 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001317 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001318
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001319 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001320 return ExprError();
1321
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001322 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001323 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1324
1325 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1326 return ExprError();
1327
1328 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001329 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1330 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001331 return ExprError();
1332 }
1333
1334 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1335}
1336
1337/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1338/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1339/// additional lookup.
1340///
1341/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1342/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1343///
1344/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001345ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001346Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001347 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001348 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001349 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001350
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001351 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1352 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1353 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1354 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1355 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1356
1357 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1358 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1359 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001360 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001361
1362 bool LookForIvars;
1363 if (Lookup.empty())
1364 LookForIvars = true;
1365 else if (IsClassMethod)
1366 LookForIvars = false;
1367 else
1368 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1369 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001370 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001371 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001372 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001373 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1374 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1375 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1376 if (IsClassMethod)
1377 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1378 << IV->getDeclName());
1379
1380 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1381 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1382 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1383 return ExprError();
1384
1385 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1386 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1387 return ExprError();
1388
1389 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1390 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1391 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1392 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1393
1394 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1395 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1396 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1397 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001398 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001399 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001400 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001401 SelfName, false, false);
1402 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1403 return Owned(new (Context)
1404 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1405 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1406 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001407 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001408 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001409 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001410 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1411 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1412 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1413 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1414 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1415 }
1416 }
1417
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001418 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1419 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1420 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1421 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1422 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1423 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1424 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1425 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1426 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1427 }
1428 }
1429 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001430 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1431 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001432}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001433
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001434/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1435///
1436/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1437///
1438/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1439/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1440/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1441/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1442///
1443/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1444/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1445/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1446/// the class declaring the member.
1447///
1448/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1449/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1450/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001451bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001452Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1453 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001454 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001455 NamedDecl *Member) {
1456 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1457 if (!RD)
1458 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001459
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001460 QualType DestRecordType;
1461 QualType DestType;
1462 QualType FromRecordType;
1463 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1464 bool PointerConversions = false;
1465 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1466 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001467
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001468 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1469 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1470 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1471 PointerConversions = true;
1472 } else {
1473 DestType = DestRecordType;
1474 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001475 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001476 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1477 if (Method->isStatic())
1478 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001479
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001480 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1481 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001482
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001483 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1484 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1485 PointerConversions = true;
1486 } else {
1487 FromRecordType = FromType;
1488 DestType = DestRecordType;
1489 }
1490 } else {
1491 // No conversion necessary.
1492 return false;
1493 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001494
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001495 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1496 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001497
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001498 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1499 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1500 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001501
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001502 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1503 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1504
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001505 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001506
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001508 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001509 // class name.
1510 //
1511 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1512 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1513 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1514 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1515 //
1516 // class Base { public: int x; };
1517 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1518 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1519 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1520 //
1521 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1522 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1523 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1524 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001525 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001526 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1527 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1528 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1529
1530 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1531
1532 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1533 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1534 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1535 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001536 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001537 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001538 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001539 return true;
1540
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001541 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001542 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001543 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1544 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001545
1546 FromType = QType;
1547 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1548
1549 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1550 // we're done.
1551 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1552 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001553 }
1554 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001555
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001556 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001557
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001558 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1559 // down to the using declaration's type.
1560 //
1561 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1562 // class ever has member declarations.
1563 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1564 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1565 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1566 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1567
1568 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1569 // conversion is non-trivial.
1570 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1571 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001572 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001573 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001574 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001575 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001576
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001577 QualType UType = URecordType;
1578 if (PointerConversions)
1579 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001580 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001581 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001582 FromType = UType;
1583 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1584 }
1585
1586 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1587 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1588 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001589 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001590
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001591 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001592 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1593 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001594 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001595 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001596
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001597 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001598 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001599 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001600}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001601
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001602/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001603static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001604 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001605 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001606 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1607 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001608 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1609 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1610 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001611 if (SS.isSet()) {
1612 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1613 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001614 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001615
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001616 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001617 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1618 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001619}
1620
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001621/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1622/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1623/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1624/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001625ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001626Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1627 LookupResult &R,
1628 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1629 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001630 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1631
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001632 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001633
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001634 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1635 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001636 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001637 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001638 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001639 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001640 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001641
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001642 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1643 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001644 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1645 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001646 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1647 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001648 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1649 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1650 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1651 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001652 }
1653
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001654 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001655 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1656 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001657 SS,
1658 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1659 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001660}
1661
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001662bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001663 const LookupResult &R,
1664 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001665 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1666 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1667 return false;
1668
1669 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001670 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001671 return false;
1672
1673 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001674 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001675 return false;
1676
1677 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1678 // normal lookup:
1679 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1680 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1681
1682 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1683 // -- a declaration of a class member
1684 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1685 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001686 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001687 return false;
1688
1689 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1690 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1691 // using-declaration
1692 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1693 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1694 // turn off ADL anyway).
1695 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1696 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1697 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1698 return false;
1699
1700 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1701 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1702 // template
1703 // And also for builtin functions.
1704 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1705 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1706
1707 // But also builtin functions.
1708 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1709 return false;
1710 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1711 return false;
1712 }
1713
1714 return true;
1715}
1716
1717
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001718/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1719/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1720/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1721/// will in fact be used.
1722static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1723 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1724 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1725 return true;
1726 }
1727
1728 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1729 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1730 return true;
1731 }
1732
1733 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1734 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1735 return true;
1736 }
1737
1738 return false;
1739}
1740
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001741ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001742Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001743 LookupResult &R,
1744 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001745 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1746 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001747 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001748 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1749 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001750
1751 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1752 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1753 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001754 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1755 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001756 return ExprError();
1757
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001758 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1759 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1760 // we've picked a target.
1761 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1762
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001763 bool Dependent
1764 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001765 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001766 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001767 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001768 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001769 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1770 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001771
1772 return Owned(ULE);
1773}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001774
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001775
1776/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001777ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001778Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001779 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1780 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001781 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001782 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1783 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001784
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001785 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001786 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1787 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001788
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001789 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1790 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1791 // a template argument list.
1792 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1793 << Template << SS.getRange();
1794 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1795 return ExprError();
1796 }
1797
1798 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1799 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1800 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001801 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001802 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001803 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001804 return ExprError();
1805 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001806
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001807 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1808 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1809 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1810 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001811 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001812 return ExprError();
1813
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001814 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1815 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001816 return ExprError();
1817
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001818 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1819 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1820 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1821 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001822 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001823 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1824 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1825 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001826 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001827 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001828 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1829 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1830 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1831 return ExprError();
1832 }
1833
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001834 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001835 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1836 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1837 return ExprError();
1838 }
1839
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001840 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001841 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001842 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001843 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001844 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001845 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1846 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001847 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001848
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001849 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001850 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001851 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1852 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001853 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001854 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1855 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1856 Expr *E = new (Context)
1857 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1858 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001859
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001860 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001861 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001862 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001863 SourceLocation(),
1864 Owned(E));
1865 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001866 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001867 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1868 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1869 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001870 }
1871 }
1872 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001873 }
1874 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1875 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001876
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001877 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1878 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001879}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001880
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001881ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001882 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001883 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001884
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001885 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001886 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001887 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1888 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1889 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001890 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001891
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001892 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1893 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001894
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001895 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001896 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1897 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001898 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001899 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001900 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001901 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001902
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001903 QualType ResTy;
1904 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1905 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1906 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001907 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001908
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001909 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001910 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001911 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1912 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001913 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001914}
1915
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001916ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001917 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001918 bool Invalid = false;
1919 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1920 if (Invalid)
1921 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001922
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001923 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1924 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001925 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001926 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001927
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001928 QualType Ty;
1929 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1930 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1931 else if (Literal.isWide())
1932 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001933 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1934 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001935 else
1936 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001937
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001938 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1939 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001940 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001941}
1942
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001943ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001944 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001945 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1946 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001947 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001948 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001949 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001950 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001951 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001952
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001953 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001954 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1955 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001956 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001957
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001958 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001959 bool Invalid = false;
1960 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1961 if (Invalid)
1962 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001963
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001964 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001965 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001966 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001967 return ExprError();
1968
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001969 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001970
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001971 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001972 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001973 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001974 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001975 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001976 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001977 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001978 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001979
1980 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1981
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001982 using llvm::APFloat;
1983 APFloat Val(Format);
1984
1985 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001986
1987 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1988 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1989 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1990 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001991 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001992 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001993 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001994 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001995 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1996 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001997 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001998 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1999 }
2000
2001 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2002 << Ty
2003 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2004 }
2005
2006 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00002007 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002008
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002009 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002010 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002011 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002012 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002013
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002014 // long long is a C99 feature.
2015 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002016 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002017 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2018
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002019 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002020 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002021
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002022 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2023 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2024 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002025 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2026 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002027 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002028 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002029 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2030 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002031
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002032 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2033 // be an unsigned int.
2034 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2035
2036 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002037 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002038 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2039 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002040 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002041
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002042 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2043 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2044 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2045 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002046 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002047 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002048 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002049 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002050 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002051 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002052
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002053 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002054 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002055 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002056
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002057 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2058 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2059 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2060 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002061 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002062 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002063 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002064 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002065 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002066 }
2067
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002068 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002069 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002070 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002071
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002072 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2073 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2074 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2075 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002076 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002077 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002078 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002079 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002080 }
2081 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002082
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002083 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2084 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002085 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002086 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002087 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002088 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002089 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002090
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002091 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2092 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002093 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002094 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002095 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002096
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002097 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2098 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002099 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002100 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002101
2102 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002103}
2104
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002105ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002106 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002107 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002108 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002109}
2110
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002111/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002112/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002113bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002114 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2115 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2116 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002117 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2118 return false;
2119
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002120 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2121 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2122 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2123 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2124 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2125 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2126
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002127 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002128 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002129 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002130 if (isSizeof)
2131 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2132 return false;
2133 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002134
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002135 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002136 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002137 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2138 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002139 return false;
2140 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002141
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002142 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002143 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2144 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002145 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002146
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002147 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002148 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002149 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002150 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2151 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002152 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002153
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002154 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2155 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2156 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2157 return true;
2158 }
2159
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002160 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002161}
2162
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002163bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2164 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2165 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002166
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002167 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002168 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2169 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002170
2171 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2172 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2173 return false;
2174
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002175 if (E->getBitField()) {
2176 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2177 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002178 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002179
2180 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2181 // bit-field.
2182 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002183 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002184 return false;
2185
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002186 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2187}
2188
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002189/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002190ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002191Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002192 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002193 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002194 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002195 return ExprError();
2196
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002197 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002198
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002199 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2200 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2201 return ExprError();
2202
2203 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002204 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002205 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2206 R.getEnd()));
2207}
2208
2209/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2210/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002211ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002212Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002213 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2214 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2215 bool isInvalid = false;
2216 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2217 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2218 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2219 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002220 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002221 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2222 isInvalid = true;
2223 } else {
2224 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2225 }
2226
2227 if (isInvalid)
2228 return ExprError();
2229
2230 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2231 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2232 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2233 R.getEnd()));
2234}
2235
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002236/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2237/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2238/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002239ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002240Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2241 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002242 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002243 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002244
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002245 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002246 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002247 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002248 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002249 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002250
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002251 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002252 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002253 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2254
2255 if (Result.isInvalid())
2256 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2257
2258 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002259}
2260
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002261QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002262 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2263 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002264
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002265 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002266 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002267 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002268
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002269 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2270 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2271 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002272
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002273 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002274 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2275 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002276 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002277}
2278
2279
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002280
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002281ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002282Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002283 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002284 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002285 switch (Kind) {
2286 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002287 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2288 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002289 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002290
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002291 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002292}
2293
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002294ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002295Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2296 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002297 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002298 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002299 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2300 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002301
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002302 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002303
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002304 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002305 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002306 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2307 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2308 }
2309
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002310 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002311 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002312 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2313 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2314 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002315 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002316 }
2317
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002318 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002319}
2320
2321
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002322ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002323Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2324 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2325 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2326 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002327
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002328 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002329 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2330 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2331 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002332
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002333 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002334
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002335 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002336 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002337 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002338 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002339 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2340 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002341 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2342 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2343 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2344 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002345 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002346 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2347 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002348 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002349 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002350 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002351 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2352 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002353 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002354 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002355 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002356 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2357 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2358 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002359 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002360 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002361 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2362 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2363 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2364 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002365 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002366 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002367 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002368
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002369 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2370 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002371 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2372 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002373 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002374 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2375 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2376 // force the promotion here.
2377 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2378 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002379 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002380 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002381 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2382
2383 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2384 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002385 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002386 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2387 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2388 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2389 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002390 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002391 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002392 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2393
2394 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2395 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002396 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002397 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002398 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2399 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002400 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002401 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002402 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002403 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2404 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002405
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002406 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002407 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2408 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002409 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2410
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002411 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002412 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2413 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002414 // incomplete types are not object types.
2415 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2416 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2417 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2418 return ExprError();
2419 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002420
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002421 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002422 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002423 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2424 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002425 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002426
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002427 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002428 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002429 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2430 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2431 return ExprError();
2432 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002433
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002434 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002435 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002436}
2437
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002438QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002439CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002440 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002441 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002442 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2443 // see FIXME there.
2444 //
2445 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2446 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002447 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002448
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002449 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002450 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002451
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002452 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002453 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2454 // to be selected.
2455 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002456
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002457 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2458 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002459 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002460
2461 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2462 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002463 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002464 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2465 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002466 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002467 do
2468 compStr++;
2469 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002470 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002471 do
2472 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002473 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002474 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002475
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002476 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002477 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2478 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002479 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002480 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002481 return QualType();
2482 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002483
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002484 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2485 // operates on.
2486 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002487 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002488
2489 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002490 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002491
2492 while (*compStr) {
2493 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2494 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2495 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2496 return QualType();
2497 }
2498 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002499 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002500
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002501 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002502 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002503 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002504 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002505 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002506 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002507 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002508 if (HexSwizzle)
2509 CompSize--;
2510
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002511 if (CompSize == 1)
2512 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002513
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002514 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002515 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002516 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2517 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2518 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2519 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002520 }
2521 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002522}
2523
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002524static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002525 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002526 const Selector &Sel,
2527 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002528
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002529 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002530 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002531 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002532 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002533
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002534 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2535 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002536 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002537 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002538 return D;
2539 }
2540 return 0;
2541}
2542
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002543static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002544 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002545 const Selector &Sel,
2546 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002547 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2548 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002549 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002550 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002551 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002552 GDecl = PD;
2553 break;
2554 }
2555 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002556 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002557 GDecl = OMD;
2558 break;
2559 }
2560 }
2561 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002562 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002563 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2564 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002565 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002566 if (GDecl)
2567 return GDecl;
2568 }
2569 }
2570 return GDecl;
2571}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002572
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002573ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002574Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002575 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002576 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2577 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002578 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002579 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002580 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2581 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2582 //
2583 // T* t;
2584 // t.f;
2585 //
2586 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2587 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2588 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2589 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002590 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002591 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2592 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002593 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002594 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002595 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002596 return ExprError();
2597 }
2598 }
2599
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002600 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2601 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002602 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002603
2604 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2605 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002606 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002607 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002608 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002609 SS.getRange(),
2610 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002611 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002612}
2613
2614/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2615/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2616/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2617static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2618 Expr *BaseExpr,
2619 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002620 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002621 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002622 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2623 // diagnostics.
2624 if (!BaseExpr)
2625 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002626
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002627 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2628 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002629}
2630
2631// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2632// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2633// type. The restriction here is:
2634//
2635// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2636// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2637// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2638//
2639// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2640// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2641// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2642// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2643bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2644 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002645 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002646 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002647 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2648 if (!BaseRT) {
2649 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2650 // dependent.
2651 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2652 return false;
2653 }
2654 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002655
2656 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002657 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2658 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002659 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002660 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002661
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002662 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002663 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2664 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2665 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002666
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002667 if (!DC->isRecord())
2668 continue;
2669
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002670 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002671 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002672
2673 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2674 return false;
2675 }
2676
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002677 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002678 return true;
2679}
2680
2681static bool
2682LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2683 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002684 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2685 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002686 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2687 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002688 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002689 << BaseRange))
2690 return true;
2691
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002692 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2693 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2694 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2695
2696 bool MOUS;
2697 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2698 return false;
2699 }
2700
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002701 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2702 if (SS.isSet()) {
2703 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2704 // nested-name-specifier.
2705 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2706
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002707 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002708 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2709 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2710 return true;
2711 }
2712
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002713 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002714
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002715 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2716 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2717 << DC << SS.getRange();
2718 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002719 }
2720 }
2721
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002722 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2723 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002724
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002725 if (!R.empty())
2726 return false;
2727
2728 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2729 // for typos.
2730 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002731 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002732 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002733 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2734 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2735 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002736 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2737 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002738 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2739 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2740 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002741 return false;
2742 } else {
2743 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002744 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002745 }
2746
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002747 return false;
2748}
2749
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002750ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002751Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002752 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002753 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002754 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002755 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002756 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002757 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2758 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002759 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002760 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2761 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002762 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002763
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002764 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002766 // Implicit member accesses.
2767 if (!Base) {
2768 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2769 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2770 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2771 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002772 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002773 return ExprError();
2774
2775 // Explicit member accesses.
2776 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002777 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002778 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002779 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002780
2781 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2782 Owned(Base);
2783 return ExprError();
2784 }
2785
2786 if (Result.get())
2787 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002788
2789 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2790 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002791 }
2792
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002793 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002794 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2795 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002796}
2797
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002798ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002799Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002800 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2801 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002802 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002803 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002804 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2805 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002806 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002807 if (IsArrow) {
2808 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2809 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2810 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002811 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002812
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002813 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002814 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2815 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2816 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002817
2818 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002819 return ExprError();
2820
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002821 if (R.empty()) {
2822 // Rederive where we looked up.
2823 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2824 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2825 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002826
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002827 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002828 << MemberName << DC
2829 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002830 return ExprError();
2831 }
2832
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002833 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2834 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2835 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2836 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2837 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2838 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2839 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2840 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2841 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2842 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002843 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002844 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002845 return ExprError();
2846
2847 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2848 // result.
2849 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002850 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002851 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002852 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002853 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002854
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002855 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2856 // pick a member.
2857 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2858
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002859 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2860 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2861 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002862 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2863 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002864 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002865 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002866 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002867
2868 return Owned(MemExpr);
2869 }
2870
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002871 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002872 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002873 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2874
2875 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2876
2877 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2878 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2879 // error cases.
2880 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2881 return ExprError();
2882
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002883 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2884 if (!BaseExpr) {
2885 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002886 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002887 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002888
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002889 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2890 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2891 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2892 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002893 }
2894
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002895 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2896 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2897 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2898 // explicitly qualified.
2899 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2900 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2901 }
2902
2903 // Check the use of this member.
2904 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2905 Owned(BaseExpr);
2906 return ExprError();
2907 }
2908
2909 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2910 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2911 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002912 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2913 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002914 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2915 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2916
2917 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2918 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2919 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2920 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2921 else {
2922 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2923 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2924 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2925
2926 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2927 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2928
2929 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2930 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2931 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2932 }
2933
2934 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002935 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002936 return ExprError();
2937 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002938 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2939 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002940 }
2941
2942 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2943 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2944 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002945 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002946 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2947 }
2948
2949 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2950 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2951 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002952 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002953 MemberFn->getType()));
2954 }
2955
2956 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2957 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2958 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002959 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2960 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002961 }
2962
2963 Owned(BaseExpr);
2964
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002965 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002966 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002967 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002968 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2969 else
2970 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2971 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002972
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002973 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2974 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002975 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002976 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002977}
2978
2979/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2980/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2981/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2982/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2983/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2984/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2985/// an ordinary member expression.
2986///
2987/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2988/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002989ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002990Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002991 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002992 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002993 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002994 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002995
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002996 // Perform default conversions.
2997 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002998
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002999 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003000 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3001
3002 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3003 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003004
3005 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003006 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003007 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3008 // call, and continue on.
3009 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3010 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3011 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3012 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3013 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003014 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3015 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003016 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3017 ->isRecordType()))) {
3018 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3019 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3020 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003021 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003022
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003023 ExprResult NewBase
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003024 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003025 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003026 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003027 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003028 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003029
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003030 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3031 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3032 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3033 }
3034 }
3035 }
3036
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003037 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3038 // use that.
3039 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003040 if (IsArrow) {
3041 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3042 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3043 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003044 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003045 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003046 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3047 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003048 }
3049 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003050 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3051 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3052 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3053 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003054 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003055 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003056 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003057
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003058 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3059 // use that.
3060 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3061 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3062 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3063 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3064 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003065 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003066 }
3067 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003068
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003069 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003070
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003071 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003072 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003073 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3074 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3075 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3076 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3077 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3078 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3079 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3080 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3081 // Check the use of this method.
3082 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3083 return ExprError();
3084 }
3085 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3086 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3087 Selector SetterSel =
3088 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3089 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3090 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3091 if (!Setter) {
3092 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3093 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003094 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003095 }
3096 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3097 if (!Setter)
3098 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003099
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003100 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3101 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003102
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003103 if (Getter || Setter) {
3104 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003105
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003106 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003107 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003108 else
3109 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3110 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3111 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003112 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003113 PType,
3114 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3115 }
3116 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3117 << MemberName << BaseType);
3118 }
3119 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003120
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003121 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3122 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3123 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003124 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003125 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003126
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003127 if (IsArrow) {
3128 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003129 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003130 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3131 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003132 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3133 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3134 // struct MyRecord foo;
3135 // foo->bar
3136 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3137 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3138 // by now.
3139 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3140 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003141 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003142 IsArrow = false;
3143 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003144 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3145 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3146 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003147 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003148 } else {
3149 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3150 // type *foo;
3151 // foo.bar
3152 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3153 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3154 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3155 // the appropriate pointer type
3156 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3157 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3158 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3159 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3160 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003161 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003162 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3163 IsArrow = true;
3164 }
3165 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003166 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003167
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003168 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003169 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003170 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003171 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003172 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003173 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003174 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003175
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003176 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3177 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003178 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003179 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003180 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003181 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3182 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3183 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3184 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003185 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3186
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003187 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003188 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003189
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003190 if (!IV) {
3191 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3192 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3193 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003194 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003195 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003196 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003197 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3198 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003199 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3200 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003201 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003202 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003203 } else {
3204 Res.clear();
3205 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003206 }
3207 }
3208
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003209 if (IV) {
3210 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3211 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3212 // error cases.
3213 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3214 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003215
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003216 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3217 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3218 return ExprError();
3219 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3220 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3221 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3222 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3223 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3224 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3225 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3226 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3227 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3228 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3229 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3230 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003231 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003232 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003233 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3234 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003235 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003236 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3237 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003238
3239 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3240 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003241 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003242 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003243 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003244 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3245 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003246 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003247 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003248 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003249
3250 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3251 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003252 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003253 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003254 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003255 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003256 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003257 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003258 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003259 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003260 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3261 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003262 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003263 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003264
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003265 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003266 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003267 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3268 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3269 // Check the use of this declaration
3270 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3271 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003272
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003273 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3274 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3275 }
3276 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3277 // Check the use of this method.
3278 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3279 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003280
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003281 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003282 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003283 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3284 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003285 }
3286 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003287
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003288 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003289 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003290 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003291
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003292 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3293 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003294 if (!IsArrow)
3295 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3296 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003297 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003298
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003299 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003300 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003301 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3302 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003303 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003304 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003305 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003306
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003307 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003308 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003309 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003310 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3311 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003312 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003313 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003314 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003315 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003316
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003317 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3318 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3319
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003320 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003321}
3322
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003323/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3324/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3325/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3326/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3327/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3328///
3329/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3330/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3331/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3332/// only be called
3333/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3334/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3335/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003336ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003337 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3338 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003339 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003340 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003341 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003342 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3343 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3344 return ExprError();
3345
3346 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3347
3348 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003349 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003350 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3351 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003352 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003353
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003354 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003355 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3356
3357 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3358 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3359 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3360
3361 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003362 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003363 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3364 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003365
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003366 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3367 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003368 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003369 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3370 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003371 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003372 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003373 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003374 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3375 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003376
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003377 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3378 Owned(Base);
3379 return ExprError();
3380 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003381
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003382 if (Result.get()) {
3383 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3384 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3385 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3386 // call now.
3387 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3388 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003389 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003390
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003391 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003392 }
3393
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003394 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003395 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3396 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003397 }
3398
3399 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003400}
3401
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003402ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003403 FunctionDecl *FD,
3404 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3405 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3406 Diag (CallLoc,
3407 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3408 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003409 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003410 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3411 } else {
3412 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3413 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3414
3415 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003416 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3417 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003418
Douglas Gregor9961ce92010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003419 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3420 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3421 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3422 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003423
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003424 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003425 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003426 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003427
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003428 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3429 InitializedEntity Entity
3430 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3431 InitializationKind Kind
3432 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3433 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3434 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3435
3436 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003437 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003438 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003439 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003440 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003441
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003442 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003443 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003444 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003445 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003446
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003447 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3448 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3449 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003450 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3451 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003452 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3453 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003454 }
3455
3456 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003457 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003458}
3459
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003460/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3461/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3462/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3463/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3464/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3465/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003466bool
3467Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003468 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003469 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003470 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3471 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003472 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003473 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3474 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003475 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003476
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003477 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3478 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3479 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3480 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3481 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003482 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003483 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003484 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003485 }
3486
3487 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3488 // them.
3489 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3490 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3491 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3492 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003493 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003494 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003495 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3496 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3497 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003498 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003499 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003500 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003501 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003502 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003503 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003504 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3505 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3506 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3507 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3508 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003509 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003510 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003511 if (Invalid)
3512 return true;
3513 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3514 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3515 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003516
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003517 return false;
3518}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003519
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003520bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3521 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3522 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3523 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3524 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3525 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003526 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003527 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3528 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3529 bool Invalid = false;
3530 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3531 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3532 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3533 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003534 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003535 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003536 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003537
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003538 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003539 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3540 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003541
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003542 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3543 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003544 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003545 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003546 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003547
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003548 // Pass the argument
3549 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3550 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3551 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003552
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003553
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003554 InitializedEntity Entity =
3555 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3556 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003557 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003558 SourceLocation(),
3559 Owned(Arg));
3560 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3561 return true;
3562
3563 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003564 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003565 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003566
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003567 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003568 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003569 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3570 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003571
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003572 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003573 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003574 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003575 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003576
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003577 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003578 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003579 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003580 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003581 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003582 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003583 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003584 }
3585 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003586 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003587}
3588
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003589/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003590/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3591/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003592ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003593Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003594 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003595 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003596 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003597
3598 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003599 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003600 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3601 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003602
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003603 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003604
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003605 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003606 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3607 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3608 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3609 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3610 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003611 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003612 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3613 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003614
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003615 NumArgs = 0;
3616 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003617
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003618 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3619 RParenLoc));
3620 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003621
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003622 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003623 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003624 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3625 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003626 bool Dependent = false;
3627 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3628 Dependent = true;
3629 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3630 Dependent = true;
3631
3632 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003633 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003634 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3635
3636 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3637 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3638 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3639 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3640
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003641 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3642
3643 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3644 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3645 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3646 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3647 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3648 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3649 // method template.
3650 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003651 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3652 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003653 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003654
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003655 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3656 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003657 }
3658
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003659 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003660 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003661 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003662 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003663 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3664 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003665 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003666
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003667 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003668 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003669 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3670 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003671 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3672 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003673 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003674
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003675 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3676 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3677 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3678 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003679
3680 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3681 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003682 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003683 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003684
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003685 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003686 RParenLoc))
3687 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003688
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003689 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003690 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003691 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003692 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3693 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003694 }
3695 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003696 }
3697
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003698 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003699 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003700 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003701
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003702 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003703 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3704 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003705 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003706 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003707 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003708
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003709 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3710 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3711 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3712
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003713 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3714}
3715
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003716/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3717/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003718/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3719/// block-pointer type.
3720///
3721/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003722ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003723Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3724 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3725 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3726 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3727 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3728
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003729 // Promote the function operand.
3730 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3731
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003732 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3733 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003734 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3735 Args, NumArgs,
3736 Context.BoolTy,
3737 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003738
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003739 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3740 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3741 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3742 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003743 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003744 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003745 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3746 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003747 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003748 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003749 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003750 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003751 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003752 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003753 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3754 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3755
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003756 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003757 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003758 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003759 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003760 return ExprError();
3761
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003762 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003763 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003764
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003765 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003766 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003767 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003768 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003769 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003770 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003771
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003772 if (FDecl) {
3773 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3774 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3775 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003776 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003777 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003778 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003779 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3780 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3781 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3782 }
3783 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003784 }
3785
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003786 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003787 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3788 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3789 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003790 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3791 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003792 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3793 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003794 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003795 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003796 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003797 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003798
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003799 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3800 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003801 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3802 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003803
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003804 // Check for sentinels
3805 if (NDecl)
3806 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003807
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003808 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003809 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003810 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003811 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003812
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003813 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003814 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003815 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003816 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003817 return ExprError();
3818 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003819
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003820 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003821}
3822
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003823ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003824Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003825 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003826 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003827 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003828 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003829
3830 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3831 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3832 if (!TInfo)
3833 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3834
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003835 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003836}
3837
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003838ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003839Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003840 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003841 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003842
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003843 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003844 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003845 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3846 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003847 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3848 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003849 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003850 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003851 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003852 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003853
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003854 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003855 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003856 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003857 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003858 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003859 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003860 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003861 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003862 &literalType);
3863 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003864 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003865 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003866
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003867 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003868 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003869 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003870 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003871 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003872
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003873 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003874 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003875}
3876
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003877ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003878Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003879 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3880 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003881 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003882
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003883 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003884 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003885
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003886 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3887 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003888 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003889 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003890}
3891
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003892static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003893 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003894 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003895 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003896
3897 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3898 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003899 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003900 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3901 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003902 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003903 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003904 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003905
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003906 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3907 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003908 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003909 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003910 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003911 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003912 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003913 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003914
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003915 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3916 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003917 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003918 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003919 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003920 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003921
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003922 // FIXME: Assert here.
3923 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003924 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003925}
3926
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003927/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003928bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003929 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003930 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003931 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003932 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003933 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3934 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003935
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003936 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003937
3938 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3939 // type needs to be scalar.
3940 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3941 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003942 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003943 return false;
3944 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003945
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003946 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3947 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3948 return true;
3949
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003950 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003951 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003952 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3953 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003954 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003955 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3956 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003957 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003958 return false;
3959 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003960
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003961 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003962 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003963 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003964 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003965 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003966 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003967 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003968 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003969 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3970 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3971 break;
3972 }
3973 }
3974 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3975 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3976 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003977 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003978 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003979 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003980
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003981 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3982 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3983 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3984 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003985
3986 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003987 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003988 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3989 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003990 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003991 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003992
3993 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003994 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003995
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003996 if (castType->isVectorType())
3997 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3998 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3999 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4000
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004001 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4002 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004003
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004004 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004005 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004006 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004007 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004008 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4009 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4010 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4011 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004012 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004013 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4014 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4015 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004016 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004017
4018 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004019
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004020 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004021 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4022
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004023 return false;
4024}
4025
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004026bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004027 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004028 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004029
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004030 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004031 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004032 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004033 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004034 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004035 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004036 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004037 } else
4038 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004039 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004040 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004041
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004042 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004043 return false;
4044}
4045
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004046bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004047 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004048 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004049
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004050 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004051
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004052 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4053 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004054 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4055 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4056 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4057 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004058 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004059 return false;
4060 }
4061
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004062 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004063 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4064 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004065 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4066 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4067 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4068 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004069
4070 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4071 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4072 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004073
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004074 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004075 return false;
4076}
4077
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004078ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004079Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004080 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4081 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004082 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004083
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004084 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4085 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4086 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004087 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004088
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004089 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4090 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004091 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004092 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004093
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004094 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004095}
4096
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004097ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004098Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004099 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004100 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004101 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004102 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004103 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004104 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004105
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004106 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004107 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004108 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4109 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004110}
4111
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004112/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4113/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004114ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004115Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004116 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4117 if (!E)
4118 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004119
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004120 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004121
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004122 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004123 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4124 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004125
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004126 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4127
4128 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004129}
4130
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004131ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004132Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004133 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004134 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004135 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004136 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004137 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004138
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004139 // Check for an altivec literal,
4140 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004141 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4142 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4143 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4144 return ExprError();
4145 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004146 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4147 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4148 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4149 }
4150 else
4151 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4152 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004153
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004154 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4155 // then handle it as such.
4156 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004157 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4158 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4159 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4160
4161 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4162 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004163 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4164 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004165 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4166 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004167 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004168 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004169 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004170 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004171 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004172 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4173 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004174 }
4175}
4176
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004177ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004178 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004179 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004180 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004181 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4182 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004183 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4184 Expr *expr;
4185 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4186 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4187 else
4188 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004189 return Owned(expr);
4190}
4191
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004192/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4193/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004194/// C99 6.5.15
4195QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4196 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004197 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4198 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4199 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4200
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004201 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4202 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4203 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4204 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4205 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4206 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004207
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004208 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004209 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4210 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4211 << CondTy;
4212 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004213 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004214
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004215 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004216 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4217 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004218
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004219 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4220 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004221 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4222 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4223 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004224 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004225
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004226 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4227 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004228 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4229 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004230 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004231 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004232 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004233 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004234 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004235 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004236
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004237 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004238 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004239 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4240 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4241 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4242 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4243 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4244 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4245 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004246 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4247 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004248 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004249 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004250 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4251 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004252 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004253 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004254 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004255 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004256 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004257 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004258 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004259 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004260 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004261 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004262 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004263
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004264 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4265 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4266 QuestionLoc);
4267 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4268 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004269
4270
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004271 // Handle block pointer types.
4272 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4273 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4274 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4275 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004276 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4277 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004278 return destType;
4279 }
4280 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004281 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004282 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004283 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004284 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4285 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4286 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004287 return LHSTy;
4288 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004289 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004290 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4291 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004292
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004293 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4294 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004295 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004296 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004297 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4298 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4299 // to get a consistent AST.
4300 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004301 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4302 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004303 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004304 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004305 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004306 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4307 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004308 return LHSTy;
4309 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004310
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004311 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4312 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4313 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004314 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4315 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004316
4317 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4318 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4319 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004320 QualType destPointee
4321 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004322 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004323 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004324 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004325 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004326 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004327 return destType;
4328 }
4329 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004330 QualType destPointee
4331 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004332 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004333 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004334 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004335 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004336 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004337 return destType;
4338 }
4339
4340 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4341 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4342 return LHSTy;
4343 }
4344 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4345 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4346 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4347 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4348 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4349 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4350 // to get a consistent AST.
4351 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004352 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4353 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004354 return incompatTy;
4355 }
4356 // The pointer types are compatible.
4357 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4358 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4359 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4360 // type.
4361 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4362 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004363 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4364 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004365 return LHSTy;
4366 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004367
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004368 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4369 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4370 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4371 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004372 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004373 return RHSTy;
4374 }
4375 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4376 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4377 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004378 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004379 return LHSTy;
4380 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004381
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004382 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004383 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4384 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004385 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004386}
4387
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004388/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4389/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4390QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4391 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4392 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4393 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004394
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004395 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4396 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4397 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4398 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4399 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004400 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004401 return LHSTy;
4402 }
4403 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4404 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004405 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004406 return RHSTy;
4407 }
4408 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4409 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4410 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004411 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004412 return LHSTy;
4413 }
4414 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4415 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004416 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004417 return RHSTy;
4418 }
4419 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4420 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4421 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004422 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004423 return LHSTy;
4424 }
4425 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4426 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004427 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004428 return RHSTy;
4429 }
4430 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4431 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004432
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004433 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4434 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4435 return LHSTy;
4436 }
4437 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4438 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4439 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004440
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004441 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4442 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4443 // type. This allows
4444 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4445 // where B is a subclass of A.
4446 //
4447 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4448 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4449 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4450 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004451
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004452 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4453 // It could return the composite type.
4454 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4455 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4456 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4457 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4458 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4459 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4460 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4461 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4462 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4463 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4464 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4465 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4466 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4467 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004468 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004469 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4470 ;
4471 else {
4472 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4473 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4474 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4475 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004476 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4477 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004478 return incompatTy;
4479 }
4480 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004481 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4482 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004483 return compositeType;
4484 }
4485 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4486 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4487 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4488 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4489 QualType destPointee
4490 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4491 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4492 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004493 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004494 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004495 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004496 return destType;
4497 }
4498 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4499 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4500 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4501 QualType destPointee
4502 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4503 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4504 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004505 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004506 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004507 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004508 return destType;
4509 }
4510 return QualType();
4511}
4512
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004513/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004514/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004515ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004516 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004517 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4518 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004519 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4520 // was the condition.
4521 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4522 if (isLHSNull)
4523 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004524
4525 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004526 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004527 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004528 return ExprError();
4529
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004530 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004531 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004532 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004533}
4534
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004535// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004536// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004537// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4538// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4539// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004540Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004541Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004542 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004543
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004544 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4545 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4546 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4547 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4548 return Compatible;
4549 }
4550
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004551 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004552 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4553 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004554
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004555 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004556 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4557 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004558
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004559 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004560
4561 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4562 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4563 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004564 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004565 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004566 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004567
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004568 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4569 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004570 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004571 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004572 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004573 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004574
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004575 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004576 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4577 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004578 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004579
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004580 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004581 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004582 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004583
4584 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004585 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4586 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004587 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004588 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004589 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004590 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4591 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4592 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4593 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4594 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4595 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004596 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004597 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004598 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004599 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004600
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004601 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004602 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004603 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004604 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004605
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004606 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4607 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4608 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4609 // warning can be disabled.
4610 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4611 return ConvTy;
4612 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4613 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004614
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004615 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4616 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4617 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4618 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4619 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4620 do {
4621 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4622 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004623
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004624 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4625 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4626 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004627
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004628 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004629 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004630 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004631
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004632 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004633 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004634 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004635 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004636}
4637
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004638/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4639/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4640/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4641// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004642Sema::AssignConvertType
4643Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004644 QualType rhsType) {
4645 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004646
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004647 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004648 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4649 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004650
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004651 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4652 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4653 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004654
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004655 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004656
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004657 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004658 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004659 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004660
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004661 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4662 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4663 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4664 }
4665 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004666 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004667 return ConvTy;
4668}
4669
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004670/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4671/// for assignment compatibility.
4672Sema::AssignConvertType
4673Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004674 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4675 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004676 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4677 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004678 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004679 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004680 }
4681 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4682 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004683 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4684 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004685 return IncompatiblePointer;
4686 return Compatible;
4687 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004688 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004689 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004690 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004691 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4692 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4693 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4694 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4695 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4696 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004697
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004698 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4699 return Compatible;
4700 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4701 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004702 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004703}
4704
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004705/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4706/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004707/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4708///
4709/// int a, *pint;
4710/// short *pshort;
4711/// struct foo *pfoo;
4712///
4713/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4714/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4715/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4716/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4717///
4718/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004719/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004720///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004721Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004722Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004723 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4724 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004725 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4726 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004727
4728 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004729 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004730
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004731 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4732 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4733 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4734 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4735 return Compatible;
4736 }
4737
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004738 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4739 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4740 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4741 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4742 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4743 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4744 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004745 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004746 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004747 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004748 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004749 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004750 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4751 // to the same ExtVector type.
4752 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4753 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4754 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004755 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004756 return Compatible;
4757 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004758
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004759 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004760 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4761 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4762 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4763 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4764 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4765 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004766 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004767
4768 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4769 // vector type and vice versa
4770 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4771 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004772 }
4773 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004774 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004775
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004776 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4777 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004778 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004779
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004780 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004781 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004782 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004783
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004784 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004785 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004786
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004787 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004788 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004789 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4790 return Compatible;
4791 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004792 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004793 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4794 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004795 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004796
4797 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004798 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004799 return Compatible;
4800 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004801 return Incompatible;
4802 }
4803
4804 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4805 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004806 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004807
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004808 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004809 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004810 return Compatible;
4811
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004812 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4813 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004814
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004815 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004816 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004817 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004818 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004819 return Incompatible;
4820 }
4821
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004822 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4823 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4824 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004825
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004826 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004827 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004828 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4829 return Compatible;
4830 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004831 }
4832 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004833 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004834 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004835 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004836 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4837 return Compatible;
4838 }
4839 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4840 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4841 return Compatible;
4842 return Incompatible;
4843 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004844 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004845 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004846 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4847 return Compatible;
4848
4849 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004850 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004851
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004852 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004853 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004854
4855 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004856 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004857 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004858 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004859 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004860 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4861 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4862 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4863 return Compatible;
4864
4865 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4866 return PointerToInt;
4867
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004868 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004869 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004870 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4871 return Compatible;
4872 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004873 }
4874 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004875 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004876 return Compatible;
4877 return Incompatible;
4878 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004879
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004880 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004881 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004882 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004883 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004884 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004885}
4886
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004887/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4888/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004889static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004890 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4891 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4892 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004893 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004894 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004895 SourceLocation());
4896 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4897 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4898
4899 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4900 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004901 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004902 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004903 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004904}
4905
4906Sema::AssignConvertType
4907Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4908 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4909
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004910 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004911 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4912 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004913 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004914 return Incompatible;
4915
4916 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4917 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4918 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4919 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004920 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4921 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004922 it != itend; ++it) {
4923 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4924 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4925 // 1) void pointer
4926 // 2) null pointer constant
4927 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004928 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004929 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004930 InitField = *it;
4931 break;
4932 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004933
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004934 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004935 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004936 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004937 InitField = *it;
4938 break;
4939 }
4940 }
4941
4942 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4943 == Compatible) {
4944 InitField = *it;
4945 break;
4946 }
4947 }
4948
4949 if (!InitField)
4950 return Incompatible;
4951
4952 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4953 return Compatible;
4954}
4955
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004956Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004957Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004958 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4959 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4960 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4961 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4962 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004963 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004964 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004965 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004966 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004967 }
4968
4969 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4970 // structures.
4971 }
4972
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004973 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4974 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004975 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4976 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004977 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004978 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004979 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004980 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004981 return Compatible;
4982 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004983
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004984 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004985 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004986 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00004987 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004988 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004989 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004990 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004991 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004992
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004993 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4994 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004995
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004996 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4997 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004998 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4999 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5000 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5001 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005002 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005003 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005004 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005005 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005006}
5007
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005008QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005009 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005010 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005011 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005012 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005013}
5014
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005015QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005016 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005017 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005018 QualType lhsType =
5019 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5020 QualType rhsType =
5021 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005022
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005023 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005024 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005025 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005026
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005027 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5028 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005029 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005030 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5031 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005032 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005033 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005034 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005035 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005036 return lhsType;
5037 }
5038
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005039 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005040 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005041 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5042 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5043 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5044 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5045 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5046 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005047 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005048 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005049 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005050
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005051 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5052 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5053 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005054 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005055 return rhsType;
5056 }
5057
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005058 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5059 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5060 bool swapped = false;
5061 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5062 swapped = true;
5063 std::swap(rex, lex);
5064 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5065 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005066
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005067 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005068 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005069 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005070 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005071 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005072 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005073 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5074 return lhsType;
5075 }
5076 }
5077 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5078 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5079 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005080 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005081 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5082 return lhsType;
5083 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005084 }
5085 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005086
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005087 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005088 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005089 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005090 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005091 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005092}
5093
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005094QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5095 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005096 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005097 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005098
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005099 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005100
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005101 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5102 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5103 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005104
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005105 // Check for division by zero.
5106 if (isDiv &&
5107 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005108 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005109 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005110
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005111 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005112}
5113
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005114QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005115 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005116 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005117 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5118 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005119 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5120 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5121 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005122
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005123 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005124
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005125 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5126 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005127
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005128 // Check for remainder by zero.
5129 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005130 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5131 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005132
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005133 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005134}
5135
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005136QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005137 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005138 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5139 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5140 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5141 return compType;
5142 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005143
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005144 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005145
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005146 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005147 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5148 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5149 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005150 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005151 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005152
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005153 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5154 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005155 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005156 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5157
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005158 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005159
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005160 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005161 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005162
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005163 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5164 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005165 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5166 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005167 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005168 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005169 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005170
5171 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5172 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5173 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005174 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005175 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5176 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5177 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5178 return QualType();
5179 }
5180
5181 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5182 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5183 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005184 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005185 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005186 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005187 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005188 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5189 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005190 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5191 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005192 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005193 return QualType();
5194 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005195 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005196 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005197 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5198 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5199 return QualType();
5200 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005201
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005202 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005203 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5204 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5205 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5206 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5207 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005208 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005209 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5210 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005211 return PExp->getType();
5212 }
5213 }
5214
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005215 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005216}
5217
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005218// C99 6.5.6
5219QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005220 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5221 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5222 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5223 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5224 return compType;
5225 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005226
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005227 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005228
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005229 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005230
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005231 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005232 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5233 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005234 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005235 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005236 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005237
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005238 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005239 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005240 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005241
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005242 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005243
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005244 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5245 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5246 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5247 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5248 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5249 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5250 return QualType();
5251 }
5252
5253 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5254 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5255 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5256 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5257 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005258 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005259 return QualType();
5260 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005261
5262 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5263 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5264 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005265 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005266 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005267 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005268 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005269 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005270
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005271 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005272 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005273 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5274 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5275 return QualType();
5276 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005277
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005278 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005279 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5280 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5281 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5282 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5283 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5284 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005285 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005286 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5287
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005288 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005289 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005290 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005291
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005292 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005293 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005294 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005295
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005296 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5297 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5298 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5299 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5300 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5301 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5302 return QualType();
5303 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005304
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005305 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5306 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5307 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5308 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005309 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005310 return QualType();
5311 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005312
5313 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5314 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5315 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5316 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5317 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005318 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5319 << rex->getSourceRange()
5320 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005321 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005322
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005323 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5324 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5325 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5326 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5327 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5328 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5329 return QualType();
5330 }
5331 } else {
5332 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5333 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5334 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5335 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5336 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5337 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5338 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5339 return QualType();
5340 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005341 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005342
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005343 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5344 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5345 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5346 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5347 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005348 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005349 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005350
5351 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005352 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5353 }
5354 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005355
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005356 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005357}
5358
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005359// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005360QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005361 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005362 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005363 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5364 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005365 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005366
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005367 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5368 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5369 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5370
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005371 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5372 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005373 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5374 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5375 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5376 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5377 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005378 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005379 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005380 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005381
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005382 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005383
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005384 // Sanity-check shift operands
5385 llvm::APSInt Right;
5386 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005387 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5388 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005389 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005390 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5391 else {
5392 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5393 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5394 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5395 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5396 }
5397 }
5398
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005399 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005400 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005401}
5402
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005403static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5404 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5405 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5406 return true;
5407 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5408 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5409 }
5410 return false;
5411}
5412
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005413// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005414QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005415 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005416 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005417
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005418 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005419 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005420 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005421
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005422 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5423 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005424
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005425 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5426 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005427 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5428 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5429 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005430 //
5431 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5432 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5433 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5434 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5435 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5436 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005437 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5438 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005439 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005440 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005441 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005442 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005443 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5444 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005445 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5446 || Opc == BO_LE
5447 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005448 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5449 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5450 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5451 // what is it always going to eval to?
5452 char always_evals_to;
5453 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005454 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005455 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5456 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005457 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005458 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5459 break;
5460 default:
5461 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5462 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5463 break;
5464 }
5465 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5466 << 1 // array
5467 << always_evals_to);
5468 }
5469 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005470 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005471
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005472 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5473 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5474 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5475 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005476
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005477 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5478 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005479 Expr *literalString = 0;
5480 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005481 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005482 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005483 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005484 literalString = lex;
5485 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005486 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5487 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005488 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005489 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005490 literalString = rex;
5491 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5492 }
5493
5494 if (literalString) {
5495 std::string resultComparison;
5496 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005497 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5498 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5499 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5500 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5501 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5502 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005503 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5504 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005505
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005506 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5507 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5508 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005509 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005510 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005511 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005512
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005513 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5514 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5515 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5516 else {
5517 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5518 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5519 }
5520
5521 lType = lex->getType();
5522 rType = rex->getType();
5523
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005524 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005525 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005526
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005527 if (isRelational) {
5528 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005529 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005530 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005531 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005532 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005533 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005534
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005535 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005536 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005537 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005538
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005539 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005540 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005541 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005542 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005543
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005544 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5545 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005546 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005547 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005548 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005549 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005550 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005551
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005552 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005553 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5554 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005555 if (!isRelational &&
5556 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5557 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5558 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005559 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5560 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005561 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5562 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005563 Diag(Loc,
5564 isSFINAEContext()?
5565 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5566 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005567 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005568
5569 if (isSFINAEContext())
5570 return QualType();
5571
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005572 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005573 return ResultTy;
5574 }
5575 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005576 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5577 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5578 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5579 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5580 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5581 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005582 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005583 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005584 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005585 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005586 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005587 if (T.isNull()) {
5588 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5589 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5590 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005591 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005592 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005593 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005594 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005595 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005596 }
5597
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005598 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5599 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005600 return ResultTy;
5601 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005602 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5603 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5604 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5605 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5606 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5607 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5608 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5609 }
5610 } else if (!isRelational &&
5611 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5612 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5613 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5614 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5615 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5616 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5617 }
5618 } else {
5619 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005620 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005621 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005622 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005623 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005624 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005625 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005626 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005627
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005628 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005629 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005630 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005631 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005632 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5633 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005634 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5635 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005636 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5637 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005638 return ResultTy;
5639 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005640 if (LHSIsNull &&
5641 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5642 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005643 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5644 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005645 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5646 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005647 return ResultTy;
5648 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005649
5650 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005651 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005652 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5653 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005654 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5655 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5656 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5657 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5658 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5659 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5660 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5661 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005662 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005663 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005664 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005665 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005666 if (T.isNull()) {
5667 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005668 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005669 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005670 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005671 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005672 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005673 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005674 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005675 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005676
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005677 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5678 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005679 return ResultTy;
5680 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005681
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005682 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005683 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5684 return ResultTy;
5685 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005686
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005687 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005688 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005689 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5690 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005691
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005692 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005693 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005694 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005695 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005696 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005697 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005698 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005699 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005700 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005701 if (!isRelational
5702 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5703 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005704 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005705 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005706 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005707 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005708 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5709 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5710 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005711 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005712 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005713 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005714 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005715
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005716 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005717 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005718 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5719 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005720 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005721 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005722 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005723 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005724
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005725 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5726 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005727 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005728 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005729 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005730 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005731 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005732 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005733 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005734 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005735 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5736 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005737 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005738 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005739 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005740 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005741 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5742 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005743 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005744 bool isError = false;
5745 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5746 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5747 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005748 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005749 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005750 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005751 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5752 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5753 isError = true;
5754 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005755 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005756
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005757 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005758 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005759 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005760 if (isError)
5761 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005762 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005763
5764 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005765 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005766 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005767 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005768 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005769 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005770
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005771 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005772 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5773 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005774 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005775 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005776 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005777 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5778 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005779 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005780 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005781 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005782 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005783}
5784
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005785/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005786/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005787/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5788/// types.
5789QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005790 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005791 bool isRelational) {
5792 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5793 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005794 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005795 if (vType.isNull())
5796 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005797
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005798 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5799 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005800
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005801 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5802 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5803 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005804 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005805 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5806 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5807 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005808 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5809 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5810 << 0 // self-
5811 << 2 // "a constant"
5812 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005813 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005814
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005815 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005816 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5817 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005818 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005819 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005820
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005821 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5822 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5823 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005824 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005825 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005826
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005827 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005828 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005829 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005830 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005831 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005832 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5833
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005834 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005835 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005836 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5837}
5838
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005839inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005840 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005841 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5842 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5843 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5844 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5845
5846 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5847 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005848
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005849 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005850
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005851 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005852 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005853 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005854}
5855
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005856inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005857 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5858
5859 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5860 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5861 // is a constant.
5862 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005863 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005864 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005865 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5866 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5867 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5868 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5869 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5870 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5871 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5872 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5873 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005874 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5875 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005876 }
5877 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005878
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005879 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5880 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5881 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005882
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005883 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5884 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005885
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005886 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005887 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005888
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005889 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5890 // non-overloadable operands.
5891
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005892 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5893 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005894 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5895 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5896 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005897 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005898
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005899 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5900 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5901 // The result is a bool.
5902 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005903}
5904
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005905/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5906/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5907/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5908///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005909static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005910 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5911 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5912 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5913 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005914 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005915 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5916 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5917 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5918 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005919 }
5920 }
5921 return false;
5922}
5923
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005924/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5925/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5926static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005927 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005928 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005929 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005930 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5931 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005932 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5933 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005934
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005935 unsigned Diag = 0;
5936 bool NeedType = false;
5937 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005938 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005939 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005940 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5941 NeedType = true;
5942 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005943 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005944 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5945 NeedType = true;
5946 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005947 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005948 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5949 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005950 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5951 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005952 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005953 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5954 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005955 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5956 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005957 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5958 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005959 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005960 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005961 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005962 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005963 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5964 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005965 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005966 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5967 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005968 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5969 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5970 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005971 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5972 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5973 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005974 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5975 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5976 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005977 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005978
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005979 SourceRange Assign;
5980 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5981 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005982 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005983 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005984 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005985 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005986 return true;
5987}
5988
5989
5990
5991// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005992QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5993 SourceLocation Loc,
5994 QualType CompoundType) {
5995 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5996 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005997 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005998
5999 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6000 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006001 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006002 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006003 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006004 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006005 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6006 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6007 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6008 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6009 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6010 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6011 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6012 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6013 }
6014 }
6015
6016 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006017 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6018 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6019 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006020 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006021 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006022 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006023 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006024
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006025 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6026 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6027 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006028 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006029 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6030 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6031 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006032 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6033 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006034 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006035 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006036 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6037 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6038 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006039 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6040 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006041 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006042 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006043 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006044 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006045 }
6046 } else {
6047 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006048 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006049 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006050
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006051 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006052 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006053 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006054
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006055
6056 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6057 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6058 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6059 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6060 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6061 // check.
6062 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006063 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006064 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6065 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6066 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6067 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6068 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6069 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6070 }
6071
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006072 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6073 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006074 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006075 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6076 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006077 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006078 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006079 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006080}
6081
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006082// C99 6.5.17
6083QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006084 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6085
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006086 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006087 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6088 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6089 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006090
6091 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6092 // incomplete in C++).
6093
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006094 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006095}
6096
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006097/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6098/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006099QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006100 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006101 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6102 return Context.DependentTy;
6103
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006104 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6105 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006106
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006107 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6108 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6109 if (!isInc) {
6110 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6111 return QualType();
6112 }
6113 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6114 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6115 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006116 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006117 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6118 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006119
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006120 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006121 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006122 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6123 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6124 << Op->getSourceRange();
6125 return QualType();
6126 }
6127
6128 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006129 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006130 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006131 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6132 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6133 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6134 return QualType();
6135 }
6136
6137 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006138 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006139 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006140 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006141 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006142 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006143 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006144 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006145 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006146 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6147 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6148 return QualType();
6149 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006150 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006151 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6152 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006153 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006154 } else {
6155 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006156 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006157 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006158 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006159 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006160 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006161 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006162 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006163 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6164 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6165 // operand.
6166 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6167 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006168}
6169
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006170/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006171/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006172/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6173/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6174/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6175/// - &(x) => x
6176/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6177/// - &s.xx => s
6178/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6179/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6180/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6181/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006182static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006183 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006184 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006185 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006186 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006187 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6188 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6189 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006190 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006191 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006192 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006193 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006194 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006195 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6196 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006197 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6198 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6199 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6200 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6201 }
6202 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006203 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006204 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6205 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006206
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006207 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006208 case UO_Real:
6209 case UO_Imag:
6210 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006211 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6212 default:
6213 return 0;
6214 }
6215 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006216 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006217 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006218 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006219 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6220 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006221 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006222 default:
6223 return 0;
6224 }
6225}
6226
6227/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006228/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006229/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006230/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006231/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006232/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006233/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006234QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6235 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006236 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006237 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6238 return Context.OverloadTy;
6239
6240 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6241 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006242
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006243 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6244 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6245 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006246 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006247 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6248 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6249 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6250 }
6251 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6252 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6253 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006254 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006255 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006256
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006257 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006258 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6259 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6260 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6261 if (isSFINAEContext())
6262 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006263 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006264 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006265 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6266 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6267 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6268
6269 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6270 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6271 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6272 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6273 return QualType();
6274 }
6275 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6276 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6277
6278 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6279 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6280 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6281 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6282
6283 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6284 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6285 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6286 << op->getSourceRange();
6287 }
6288
6289 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6290 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6291 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006292 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006293 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006294 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006295 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006296 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6297 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006298 return QualType();
6299 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006300 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006301 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6302 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6303 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006304 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006305 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006306 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006307 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006308 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006309 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006310 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6311 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6312 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6313 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6314 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006315 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6316 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006317 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6318 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006319 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006320 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006321 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6322 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006323 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6324 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006325 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006326 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006327 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6328 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006329 return QualType();
6330 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006331 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006332 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006333 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006334 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006335 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6336 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006337 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006338 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006339 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6340 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006341 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006342 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6343 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6344 return QualType();
6345 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006346
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006347 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6348 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006349 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006350 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006351 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006352 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006353 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006354
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006355 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6356 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6357 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6358 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6359 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6360 }
6361
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006362 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006363 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6364 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006365 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006366}
6367
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006368/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006369QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006370 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6371 return Context.DependentTy;
6372
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006373 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006374 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6375 QualType Result;
6376
6377 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6378 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6379 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6380 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6381 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6382 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6383 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6384 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6385 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006386
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006387 if (Result.isNull()) {
6388 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6389 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6390 return QualType();
6391 }
6392
6393 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006394}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006395
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006396static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006397 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006398 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006399 switch (Kind) {
6400 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006401 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6402 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6403 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6404 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6405 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6406 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6407 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6408 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6409 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6410 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6411 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6412 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6413 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6414 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6415 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6416 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6417 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6418 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6419 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6420 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6421 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6422 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6423 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6424 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6425 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6426 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6427 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6428 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6429 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6430 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6431 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6432 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006433 }
6434 return Opc;
6435}
6436
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006437static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006438 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006439 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006440 switch (Kind) {
6441 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006442 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6443 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6444 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6445 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6446 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6447 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6448 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6449 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6450 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6451 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6452 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006453 }
6454 return Opc;
6455}
6456
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006457/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6458/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6459/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006460ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006461 unsigned Op,
6462 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006463 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006464 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006465 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6466 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6467 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006468
6469 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006470 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006471 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6472 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006473 case BO_PtrMemD:
6474 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006475 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006476 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006477 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006478 case BO_Mul:
6479 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006480 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006481 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006482 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006483 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006484 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6485 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006486 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006487 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6488 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006489 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006490 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6491 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006492 case BO_Shl:
6493 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006494 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6495 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006496 case BO_LE:
6497 case BO_LT:
6498 case BO_GE:
6499 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006500 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006501 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006502 case BO_EQ:
6503 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006504 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006505 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006506 case BO_And:
6507 case BO_Xor:
6508 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006509 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6510 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006511 case BO_LAnd:
6512 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006513 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006514 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006515 case BO_MulAssign:
6516 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006517 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006518 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006519 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6520 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6521 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006522 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006523 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006524 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6525 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6526 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6527 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006528 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006529 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006530 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6531 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6532 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006533 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006534 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006535 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6536 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6537 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006538 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006539 case BO_ShlAssign:
6540 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006541 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6542 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6543 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6544 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006545 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006546 case BO_AndAssign:
6547 case BO_XorAssign:
6548 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006549 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6550 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6551 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6552 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006553 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006554 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006555 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6556 break;
6557 }
6558 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006559 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006560 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006561 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006562 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6563 << ResultTy;
6564 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006565 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006566 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6567 else
6568 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006569 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6570 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006571}
6572
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006573/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6574/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006575static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6576 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006577 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6578 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6579 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006580 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006581 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6582
6583 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6584 return;
6585
6586 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6587 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6588 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006589 return;
6590 }
6591
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006592 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6593 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006594 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006595
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006596 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006597 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006598
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006599 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6600 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6601 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6602 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006603 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006604 return;
6605 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006606
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006607 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006608 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6609 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006610}
6611
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006612/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6613/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6614/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6615/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006616static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006617 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006618 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6619 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6620 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6621 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006622 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006623 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006624 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6625
6626 // Subs are not binary operators.
6627 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6628 return;
6629
6630 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6631 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006632 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6633 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006634 return;
6635
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006636 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006637 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006638 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006639 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6640 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006641 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006642 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006643 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6644 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6645 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6646 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006647 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006648 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006649 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006650 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6651 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006652 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006653 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006654 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6655 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6656 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6657 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006658}
6659
6660/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6661/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6662/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006663static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006664 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006665 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006666 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6667}
6668
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006669// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006670ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006671 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6672 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6673 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006674 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6675 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006676
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006677 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6678 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6679
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006680 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6681}
6682
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006683ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006684 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6685 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006686 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006687 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006688 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6689 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6690 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6691 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6692 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006693 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006694 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006695 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6696 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6697 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006698
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006699 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6700 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006701 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006702 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006703
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006704 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006705 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006706}
6707
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006708ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006709 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006710 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006711 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006712
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006713 QualType resultType;
6714 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006715 case UO_PreInc:
6716 case UO_PreDec:
6717 case UO_PostInc:
6718 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006719 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006720 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6721 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6722 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6723 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006724 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006725 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006726 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006727 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006728 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006729 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006730 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006731 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006732 case UO_Plus:
6733 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006734 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6735 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006736 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6737 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006738 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6739 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006740 break;
6741 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6742 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6743 break;
6744 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006745 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006746 resultType->isPointerType())
6747 break;
6748
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006749 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6750 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006751 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006752 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6753 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006754 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6755 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006756 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6757 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6758 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006759 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006760 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006761 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006762 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6763 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006764 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006765 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006766 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006767 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006768 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006769 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6770 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006771 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006772 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6773 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006774 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006775 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6776 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006777 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006778 case UO_Real:
6779 case UO_Imag:
6780 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006781 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006782 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006783 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006784 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006785 }
6786 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006787 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006788
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006789 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006790}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006791
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006792ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006793 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6794 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006795 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006796 Opc != UO_Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006797 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6798 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6799 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6800 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006801 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006802 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006803 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6804 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6805 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006806
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006807 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006808 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006809
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006810 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006811}
6812
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006813// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006814ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006815 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6816 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006817}
6818
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006819/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006820ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006821 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6822 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006823 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006824 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006825
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006826 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6827 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006828 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006829 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006830
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006831 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006832 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6833 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006834}
6835
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006836ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006837Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006838 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006839 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6840 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6841
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006842 bool isFileScope
6843 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006844 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006845 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006846
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006847 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6848 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6849 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006850
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006851 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6852 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6853 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006854
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006855 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6856 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6857 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6858 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6859 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006860
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006861 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006862 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006863 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006864
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006865 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6866 // expressions are not lvalues.
6867
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006868 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006869}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006870
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006871ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006872 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006873 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6874 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006875 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6876 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006877 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006878 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006879
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006880 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6881 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6882 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006883 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006884 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6885 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6886
6887 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6888 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6889 if (!Dependent
6890 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6891 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6892 << TypeRange))
6893 return ExprError();
6894
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006895 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6896 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006897 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6898 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006899 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006900 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6901 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006902
6903 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6904 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6905 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6906 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6907 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6908 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6909 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6910 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6911 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6912 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6913 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6914 if(!AT)
6915 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6916 << CurrentType);
6917 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6918 } else
6919 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6920
6921 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6922 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6923 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6924 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6925 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6926 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6927 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6928 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6929
6930 // Record this array index.
6931 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6932 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6933 continue;
6934 }
6935
6936 // Offset of a field.
6937 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6938 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6939 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6940 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6941 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6942 continue;
6943 }
6944
6945 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6946 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6947 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6948 return ExprError();
6949
6950 // Look for the designated field.
6951 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6952 if (!RC)
6953 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6954 << CurrentType);
6955 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6956
6957 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6958 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6959 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6960 // (clause 9).
6961 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6962 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6963 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6964 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6965 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6966 << CurrentType))
6967 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6968 }
6969
6970 // Look for the field.
6971 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6972 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6973 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6974 if (!MemberDecl)
6975 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6976 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6977 OC.LocEnd));
6978
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006979 // C99 7.17p3:
6980 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6981 //
6982 // We diagnose this as an error.
6983 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6984 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6985 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6986 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6987 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6988 return ExprError();
6989 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006990
6991 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
6992 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
6993 if (AnonStructUnion) {
6994 do {
6995 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
6996 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
6997 }
6998
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006999 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7000 // the base class indirections.
7001 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7002 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007003 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007004 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7005 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7006 B != BEnd; ++B)
7007 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7008 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007009
7010 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007011 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7012 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7013 unsigned n = Path.size();
7014 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7015 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7016 } else {
7017 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7018 }
7019 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7020 }
7021
7022 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7023 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7024 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7025}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007026
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007027ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007028 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7029 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007030 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007031 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7032 unsigned NumComponents,
7033 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7034
7035 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7036 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7037 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7038 return ExprError();
7039
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007040 if (!ArgTInfo)
7041 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7042
7043 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7044 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007045}
7046
7047
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007048ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007049 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007050 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007051 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7052 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7053 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7054 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007055
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007056 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007057
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007058 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7059}
7060
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007061ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007062Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7063 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7064 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7065 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007066 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7067 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7068 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7069 return ExprError();
7070 }
7071
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007072 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007073 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007074}
7075
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007076
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007077ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007078 Expr *CondExpr,
7079 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007080 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007081 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7082
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007083 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007084 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007085 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007086 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007087 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007088 } else {
7089 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7090 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7091 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7092 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007093 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7094 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7095 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007096
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007097 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7098 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007099 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7100 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007101 }
7102
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007103 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007104 resType, RPLoc,
7105 resType->isDependentType(),
7106 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007107}
7108
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007109//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7110// Clang Extensions.
7111//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7112
7113/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007114void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007115 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7116 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7117 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007118 if (BlockScope)
7119 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7120 else
7121 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007122}
7123
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007124void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007125 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007126 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007127
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007128 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007129 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007130 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007131
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007132 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007133 QualType RetTy;
7134 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007135 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007136 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007137 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007138 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7139 } else {
7140 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007141 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007142 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007143
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007144 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007145
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007146 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7147 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7148 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007149 return;
7150 }
7151
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007152 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7153 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7154 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7155 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7156 return;
7157 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007158
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007159 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007160 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7161 // ^ * { ... }
7162 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007163 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7164 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007165
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007166 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007167 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007168 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7169 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7170 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7171 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007172 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7173 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7174 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7175 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7176 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007177 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007178 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007179
7180 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7181 // ^ fntype { ... }
7182 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7183 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7184 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7185 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7186 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7187 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7188 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007189 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007190 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007191 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007192
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007193 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7194 if (!Params.empty())
7195 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007196
7197 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007198 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007199
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007200 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007201 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7202 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7203 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7204 }
7205
7206 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7207 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007208 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007209 return;
7210
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007211 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7212 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7213
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007214 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007215 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7216 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7217
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007218 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007219 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7220 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7221 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7222
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007223 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007224 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007225 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007226}
7227
7228/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7229/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7230void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007231 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007232 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007233 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007234 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007235}
7236
7237/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7238/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007239ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007240 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007241 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7242 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7243 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007244
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007245 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007246
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007247 PopDeclContext();
7248
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007249 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007250 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7251 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007252
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007253 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007254 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007255
7256 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7257 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7258 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7259
7260 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7261 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7262
7263 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7264 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7265 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7266 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7267
7268 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7269 // preserve its sugar structure.
7270 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7271 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7272 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7273
7274 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7275 } else {
7276 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7277 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7278 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7279 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7280 FPT->isVariadic(),
7281 /*quals*/ 0,
7282 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7283 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7284 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7285 FPT->exception_begin(),
7286 Ext);
7287 }
7288
7289 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7290 } else {
7291 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7292 false, false, 0, 0,
7293 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7294 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007295
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007296 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007297 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7298 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007299 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007300
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007301 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007302 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007303 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007304
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007305 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007306
7307 bool Good = true;
7308 // Check goto/label use.
7309 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7310 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7311 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7312
7313 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7314 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7315 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7316 continue;
7317
7318 // Emit error.
7319 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7320 Good = false;
7321 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007322 if (!Good) {
7323 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007324 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007325 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007326
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007327 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7328 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7329
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007330 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007331 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7332 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007333 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007334
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007335 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007336 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007337}
7338
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007339ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007340 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007341 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007342 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7343 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007344 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007345}
7346
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007347ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007348 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007349 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007350 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007351
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007352 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007353
7354 // Get the va_list type
7355 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007356 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7357 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7358 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7359 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007360 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007361 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7362 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7363 } else {
7364 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7365 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007366 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007367 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007368 return ExprError();
7369 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007370
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007371 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7372 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007373 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7374 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007375 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007376 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007377
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007378 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007379 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007380
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007381 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7382 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007383}
7384
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007385ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007386 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7387 // pointers on the target.
7388 QualType Ty;
7389 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7390 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7391 else
7392 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7393
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007394 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007395}
7396
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007397static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007398 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007399 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7400 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007401
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007402 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7403 if (!PT)
7404 return;
7405
7406 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7407 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7408 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7409 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7410 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7411 return;
7412 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007413
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007414 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7415 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7416 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7417 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007418
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007419 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007420}
7421
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007422bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7423 SourceLocation Loc,
7424 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007425 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7426 bool *Complained) {
7427 if (Complained)
7428 *Complained = false;
7429
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007430 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7431 bool isInvalid = false;
7432 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007433 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007434
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007435 switch (ConvTy) {
7436 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7437 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007438 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007439 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7440 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007441 case IntToPointer:
7442 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7443 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007444 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007445 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007446 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7447 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007448 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7449 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7450 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007451 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7452 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7453 break;
7454 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007455 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7456 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7457 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7458 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7459 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7460 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7461 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7462 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7463 // C++ semantics.
7464 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7465 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7466 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007467 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7468 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007469 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007470 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007471 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007472 case IntToBlockPointer:
7473 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7474 break;
7475 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007476 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007477 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007478 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007479 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007480 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7481 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7482 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007483 case IncompatibleVectors:
7484 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7485 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007486 case Incompatible:
7487 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7488 isInvalid = true;
7489 break;
7490 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007491
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007492 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7493 switch (Action) {
7494 case AA_Assigning:
7495 case AA_Initializing:
7496 // The destination type comes first.
7497 FirstType = DstType;
7498 SecondType = SrcType;
7499 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007500
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007501 case AA_Returning:
7502 case AA_Passing:
7503 case AA_Converting:
7504 case AA_Sending:
7505 case AA_Casting:
7506 // The source type comes first.
7507 FirstType = SrcType;
7508 SecondType = DstType;
7509 break;
7510 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007511
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007512 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007513 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007514 if (Complained)
7515 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007516 return isInvalid;
7517}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007518
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007519bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007520 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7521 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7522 if (Result)
7523 *Result = ICEResult;
7524 return false;
7525 }
7526
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007527 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7528
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007529 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007530 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7531 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7532
7533 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7534 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7535 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7536 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7537 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7538 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7539 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007540
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007541 return true;
7542 }
7543
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007544 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7545 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007546
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007547 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7548 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7549 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007550
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007551 if (Result)
7552 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7553 return false;
7554}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007555
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007556void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007557Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007558 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7559 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007560}
7561
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007562void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007563Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7564 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7565 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7566 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007567
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007568 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7569 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7570 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7571 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7572 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007573 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007574 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7575 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7576 I != IEnd; ++I)
7577 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7578 }
7579
7580 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7581 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7582 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7583 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7584 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7585 I != IEnd; ++I)
7586 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7587 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007588 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007589
7590 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7591 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7592 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7593 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007594 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007595 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7596 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7597 ExprTemporaries.end());
7598
7599 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7600 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007601}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007602
7603/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7604///
7605/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7606/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7607/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7608/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7609///
7610/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7611///
7612/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7613void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7614 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007615
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007616 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007617 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007618
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007619 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7620 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7621 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7622 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007623 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007624 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007625 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007626 return;
7627 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007628
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007629 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7630 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007631
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007632 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7633 // an instantiation.
7634 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7635 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007636
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007637 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007638 case Unevaluated:
7639 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7640 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007641
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007642 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7643 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7644 // "used"; handle this below.
7645 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007646
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007647 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7648 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7649 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7650 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007651 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007652 return;
7653 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007654
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007655 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007656 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007657 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007658 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007659 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7660 return;
7661 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7662 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007663 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007664 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007665 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007666 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7667 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007668
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007669 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007670 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007671 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007672 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007673 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7674 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007675 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7676 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7677 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007678 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007679 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007680 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7681 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007682 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007683 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007684 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007685 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007686 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007687 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7688 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7689 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7690 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7691 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007692 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007693 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007694 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007695 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007696 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7697 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7698 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007699 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007700 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007701 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7702 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007703
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007704 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7705 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7706 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7707 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7708 Loc));
7709 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007710 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007711 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007712 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7713 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7714 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
7715 if (i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
7716 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7717 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007718
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007719 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007720
7721 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7722 if (CurContext != Function)
7723 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007724
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007725 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007726 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007727
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007728 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007729 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007730 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007731 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7732 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7733 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7734 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7735 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7736 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007737 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007738 }
7739 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007740
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007741 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007742
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007743 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007744 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007745 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007746}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007747
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007748namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007749 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007750 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007751 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007752 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7753 Sema &S;
7754 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007755
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007756 public:
7757 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007758
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007759 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007760
7761 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7762 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007763 };
7764}
7765
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007766bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7767 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007768 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7769 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7770 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007771
7772 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007773}
7774
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007775bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007776 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7777 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7778 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007779 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7780 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007781 }
7782
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007783 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007784}
7785
7786void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7787 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007788 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007789}
7790
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007791/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7792/// of the program being compiled.
7793///
7794/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007795/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007796/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7797/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7798/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7799/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007800/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007801/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007802///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007803/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7804/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7805/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7806/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007807bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007808 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7809 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7810 case Unevaluated:
7811 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7812 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007813
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007814 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7815 Diag(Loc, PD);
7816 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007817
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007818 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7819 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7820 break;
7821 }
7822
7823 return false;
7824}
7825
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007826bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7827 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7828 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7829 return false;
7830
7831 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7832 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7833 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7834 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007835
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007836 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007837 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007838 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7839 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007840 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007841 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7842 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7843 return true;
7844
7845 return false;
7846}
7847
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007848// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7849// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7850void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7851 SourceLocation Loc;
7852
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007853 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7854
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007855 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7856 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007857 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007858 return;
7859
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007860 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7861 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7862 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7863 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7864
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007865 // self = [<foo> init...]
7866 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7867 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7868 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7869
7870 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7871 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7872 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7873 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7874 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007875
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007876 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7877 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7878 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7879 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7880 return;
7881
7882 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7883 } else {
7884 // Not an assignment.
7885 return;
7886 }
7887
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007888 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007889 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007890
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007891 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007892 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007893 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007894 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7895 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7896 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007897}
7898
7899bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7900 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7901
7902 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007903 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007904
7905 QualType T = E->getType();
7906
7907 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7908 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7909 return true;
7910 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7911 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7912 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7913 return true;
7914 }
7915 }
7916
7917 return false;
7918}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007919
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007920ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7921 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007922 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007923 return ExprError();
7924
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007925 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007926 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007927
7928 return Owned(Sub);
7929}